xref: /linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 0e685c3e7158d35626d6d76b9f859eae806d87fa)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2022 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217  */
218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
220 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
221 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
222 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
224 };
225 
226 /**
227  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228  *
229  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231  *
232  * @def: the channel definition
233  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242  */
243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246 
247 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248 
249 	bool radar_enabled;
250 
251 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252 };
253 
254 /**
255  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
259  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266  *      for changes/removal.)
267  */
268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271 };
272 
273 /**
274  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275  *
276  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
278  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279  * done.
280  *
281  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285  */
286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291 };
292 
293 /**
294  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295  *
296  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298  *
299  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300  *	also implies a change in the AID.
301  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
311  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324  *	changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329  *	context had been assigned.
330  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333  *	keep alive) changed.
334  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342  *	status changed.
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
344  */
345 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
346 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
347 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
348 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
349 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
350 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
351 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
352 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
353 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
354 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
355 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
356 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
357 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
358 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
359 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
360 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
361 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
362 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
363 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
364 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
365 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
366 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
367 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
368 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
369 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
370 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING	= BIT_ULL(32),
379 
380 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
381 };
382 
383 /*
384  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
385  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
386  * filtering will be disabled.
387  */
388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
389 
390 /**
391  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
392  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
393  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
394  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
395  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
396  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
397  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
398  */
399 enum ieee80211_event_type {
400 	RSSI_EVENT,
401 	MLME_EVENT,
402 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
403 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
404 };
405 
406 /**
407  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
408  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
409  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
410  */
411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
412 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
413 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
414 };
415 
416 /**
417  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
418  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
419  */
420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
421 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
422 };
423 
424 /**
425  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
426  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
427  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
428  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
429  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
430  */
431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
432 	AUTH_EVENT,
433 	ASSOC_EVENT,
434 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
435 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
436 };
437 
438 /**
439  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
440  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
441  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
442  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
443  */
444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
445 	MLME_SUCCESS,
446 	MLME_DENIED,
447 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
448 };
449 
450 /**
451  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
452  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
453  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
454  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
455  */
456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
457 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
458 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
459 	u16 reason;
460 };
461 
462 /**
463  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
464  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
465  * @tid: the tid
466  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
467  */
468 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
469 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
470 	u16 tid;
471 	u16 ssn;
472 };
473 
474 /**
475  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
476  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
477  * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
478  * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
479  * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
480  * @u:union holding the fields above
481  */
482 struct ieee80211_event {
483 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
484 	union {
485 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
486 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
487 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
488 	} u;
489 };
490 
491 /**
492  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
493  *
494  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
495  *
496  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
497  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
498  */
499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
500 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
501 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
502 };
503 
504 /**
505  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
506  *
507  * @lci: LCI subelement content
508  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
509  * @lci_len: LCI data length
510  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
511  */
512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
513 	const u8 *lci;
514 	const u8 *civicloc;
515 	size_t lci_len;
516 	size_t civicloc_len;
517 };
518 
519 /**
520  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
521  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
522  *
523  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
524  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
525  */
526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
527 	u32 min_interval;
528 	u32 max_interval;
529 };
530 
531 /**
532  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
533  *
534  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
535  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
536  *
537  * @addr: (link) address used locally
538  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
539  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
540  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
541  * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
542  *	ACK, BACK or both
543  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
544  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
545  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
546  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
547  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
548  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
549  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
550  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
551  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
552  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
553  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
554  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
555  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
556  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
557  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
558  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
559  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
560  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
561  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
562  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
563  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
564  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
565  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
566  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
567  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
568  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
569  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
570  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
571  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
572  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
573  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
574  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
575  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
576  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
577  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
578  *	the current band.
579  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
580  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
581  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
582  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
583  * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
584  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
585  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
586  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
587  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
588  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
589  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
590  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
591  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
592  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
593  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
594  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
595  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
596  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
597  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
598  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
599  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
600  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
601  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
602  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
603  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
604  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
605  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
606  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
607  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
608  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
609  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
610  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
611  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
612  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
613  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
614  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
615  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
616  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
617  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
618  *	station.
619  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
620  *	responder functionality.
621  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
622  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
623  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
624  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
625  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
626  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
627  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
628  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
629  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
630  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
631  *	connected to (STA)
632  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
633  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
634  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
635  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
636  *	interval.
637  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
638  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
639  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
640  * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
641  * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
642  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
643  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
644  * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
645  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
646  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
647  *	for read access.
648  * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
649  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
650  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
651  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
652  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
653  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
654  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
655  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing. Internally it is
656  *	write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
657  *	for read access.
658  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
659  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
660  *	beamformer
661  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
662  *	beamformee
663  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
664  *	beamformer
665  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
666  *	beamformee
667  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
668  *	beamformer
669  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
670  *	beamformee
671  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
672  *	beamformer
673  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
674  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
675  *	bandwidth
676  */
677 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
678 	const u8 *bssid;
679 	unsigned int link_id;
680 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
681 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
682 	bool uora_exists;
683 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
684 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
685 	bool he_support;
686 	bool twt_requester;
687 	bool twt_responder;
688 	bool twt_protected;
689 	bool twt_broadcast;
690 	/* erp related data */
691 	bool use_cts_prot;
692 	bool use_short_preamble;
693 	bool use_short_slot;
694 	bool enable_beacon;
695 	u8 dtim_period;
696 	u16 beacon_int;
697 	u16 assoc_capability;
698 	u64 sync_tsf;
699 	u32 sync_device_ts;
700 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
701 	u32 basic_rates;
702 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
703 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
704 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
705 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
706 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
707 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
708 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
709 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
710 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
711 	bool qos;
712 	bool hidden_ssid;
713 	int txpower;
714 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
715 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
716 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
717 	u16 max_idle_period;
718 	bool protected_keep_alive;
719 	bool ftm_responder;
720 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
721 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
722 	bool nontransmitted;
723 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
724 	u8 bssid_index;
725 	u8 bssid_indicator;
726 	bool ema_ap;
727 	u8 profile_periodicity;
728 	struct {
729 		u32 params;
730 		u16 nss_set;
731 	} he_oper;
732 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
733 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
734 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
735 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
736 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
737 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
738 	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
739 	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
740 	u8 pwr_reduction;
741 	bool eht_support;
742 	u16 eht_puncturing;
743 
744 	bool csa_active;
745 	u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
746 
747 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
748 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
749 
750 	bool color_change_active;
751 	u8 color_change_color;
752 
753 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
754 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
755 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
756 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
757 	bool he_su_beamformer;
758 	bool he_su_beamformee;
759 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
760 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
761 };
762 
763 /**
764  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
765  *
766  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
767  *
768  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
769  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
770  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
771  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
772  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
773  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
774  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
775  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
776  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
777  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
778  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
779  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
780  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
781  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
782  *	station
783  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
784  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
785  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
786  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
787  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
788  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
789  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
790  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
791  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
792  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
793  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
794  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
795  *	hardware queue.
796  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
797  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
798  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
799  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
800  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
801  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
802  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
803  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
804  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
805  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
806  *	off-channel operation.
807  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
808  *	(header conversion)
809  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
810  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
811  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
812  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
813  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
814  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
815  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
816  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
817  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
818  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
819  *	queue gets full.
820  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
821  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
822  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
823  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
824  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
825  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
826  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
827  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
828  *	status to user space)
829  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
830  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
831  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
832  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
833  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
834  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
835  *	handled properly by the device.
836  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
837  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
838  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
839  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
840  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
841  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
842  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
843  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
844  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
845  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
846  *	PS-Poll responses.
847  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
848  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
849  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
850  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
851  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
852  *	monitor injection).
853  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
854  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
855  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
856  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
857  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
858  *
859  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
860  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
861  */
862 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
863 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
864 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
865 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
866 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
867 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
868 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
869 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
870 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
871 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
872 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
873 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
874 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
875 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
876 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
877 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
878 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
879 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
880 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
881 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
882 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
883 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
884 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
885 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
886 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
887 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
888 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
889 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
890 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
891 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
892 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
893 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
894 };
895 
896 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
897 
898 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
899 
900 /**
901  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
902  *
903  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
904  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
905  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
906  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
907  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
908  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
909  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
910  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
911  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
912  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
913  *	it can be sent out.
914  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
915  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
916  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
917  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
918  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
919  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
920  *	for sequence number assignment
921  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
922  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
923  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
924  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
925  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
926  *	it's intended for an MLD.
927  *
928  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
929  */
930 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
931 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
932 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
933 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
934 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
935 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
936 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
937 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
938 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
939 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
940 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
941 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
942 };
943 
944 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
945 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
946 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
947 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
948 
949 /**
950  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
951  *
952  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
953  *
954  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
955  */
956 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
957 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
958 };
959 
960 /*
961  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
962  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
963  */
964 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
965 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
966 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
967 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
968 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
969 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
970 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
971 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
972 
973 /**
974  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
975  *	Rate Control algorithm.
976  *
977  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
978  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
979  *
980  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
981  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
982  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
983  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
984  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
985  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
986  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
987  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
988  *	Greenfield mode.
989  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
990  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
991  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
992  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
993  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
994  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
995  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
996  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
997  */
998 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
999 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1000 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1001 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1002 
1003 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1004 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1005 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1006 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1007 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1008 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1009 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1010 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1011 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1012 };
1013 
1014 
1015 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1016 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1017 
1018 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1019 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1020 
1021 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1022 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1023 
1024 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1025 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1026 
1027 /**
1028  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1029  *
1030  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1031  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1032  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1033  *
1034  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1035  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1036  *
1037  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1038  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1039  *
1040  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1041  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1042  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1043  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1044  * information::
1045  *
1046  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1047  *
1048  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1049  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1050  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1051  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1052  * information should then contain::
1053  *
1054  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1055  *
1056  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1057  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1058  */
1059 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1060 	s8 idx;
1061 	u16 count:5,
1062 	    flags:11;
1063 } __packed;
1064 
1065 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1066 
1067 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1068 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1069 {
1070 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1071 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1072 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1073 }
1074 
1075 static inline u8
1076 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1077 {
1078 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1079 }
1080 
1081 static inline u8
1082 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1083 {
1084 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1085 }
1086 
1087 /**
1088  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1089  *
1090  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1091  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1092  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1093  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1094  *
1095  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1096  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1097  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1098  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1099  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1100  * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
1101  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1102  * @control: union part for control data
1103  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1104  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1105  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1106  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1107  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1108  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1109  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1110  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1111  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1112  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1113  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1114  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1115  * @pad: padding
1116  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1117  * @status: union part for status data
1118  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1119  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1120  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1121  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1122  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1123  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1124  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1125  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1126  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1127  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1128  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1129  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1130  * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1131  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1132  * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1133  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1134  * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1135  */
1136 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1137 	/* common information */
1138 	u32 flags;
1139 	u32 band:3,
1140 	    ack_frame_id:13,
1141 	    hw_queue:4,
1142 	    tx_time_est:10;
1143 	/* 2 free bits */
1144 
1145 	union {
1146 		struct {
1147 			union {
1148 				/* rate control */
1149 				struct {
1150 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1151 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1152 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1153 					u8 use_rts:1;
1154 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1155 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1156 					u8 skip_table:1;
1157 					/* 2 bytes free */
1158 				};
1159 				/* only needed before rate control */
1160 				unsigned long jiffies;
1161 			};
1162 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1163 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1164 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1165 			u32 flags;
1166 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1167 		} control;
1168 		struct {
1169 			u64 cookie;
1170 		} ack;
1171 		struct {
1172 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1173 			s32 ack_signal;
1174 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1175 			u8 ampdu_len;
1176 			u8 antenna;
1177 			u16 tx_time;
1178 			u8 flags;
1179 			void *status_driver_data[18 / sizeof(void *)];
1180 		} status;
1181 		struct {
1182 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1183 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1184 			u8 pad[4];
1185 
1186 			void *rate_driver_data[
1187 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1188 		};
1189 		void *driver_data[
1190 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1191 	};
1192 };
1193 
1194 static inline u16
1195 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1196 {
1197 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1198 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1199 	 */
1200 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1201 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1202 }
1203 
1204 static inline u16
1205 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1206 {
1207 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1208 }
1209 
1210 /***
1211  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1212  *
1213  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1214  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1215  *
1216  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1217  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1218  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1219  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1220  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1221  */
1222 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1223 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1224 	u8 try_count;
1225 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1226 };
1227 
1228 /**
1229  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1230  *
1231  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1232  * @info: Basic tx status information
1233  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1234  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1235  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1236  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1237  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1238  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1239  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1240  */
1241 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1242 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1243 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1244 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1245 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1246 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1247 	u8 n_rates;
1248 
1249 	struct list_head *free_list;
1250 };
1251 
1252 /**
1253  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1254  *
1255  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1256  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1257  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1258  *
1259  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1260  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1261  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1262  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1263  */
1264 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1265 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1266 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1267 	const u8 *common_ies;
1268 	size_t common_ie_len;
1269 };
1270 
1271 
1272 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1273 {
1274 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1275 }
1276 
1277 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1278 {
1279 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1280 }
1281 
1282 /**
1283  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1284  *
1285  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1286  *
1287  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1288  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1289  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1290  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1291  *
1292  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1293  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1294  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1295  */
1296 static inline void
1297 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1298 {
1299 	int i;
1300 
1301 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1302 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1303 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1304 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1305 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1306 	/* clear the rate counts */
1307 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1308 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1309 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1310 }
1311 
1312 
1313 /**
1314  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1315  *
1316  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1317  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1318  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1319  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1320  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1321  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1322  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1323  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1324  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1325  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1326  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1327  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1328  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1329  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1330  *	de-duplication by itself.
1331  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1332  *	the frame.
1333  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1334  *	the frame.
1335  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1336  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1337  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1338  *	merging.
1339  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1340  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1341  *	(including FCS) was received.
1342  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1343  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1344  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1345  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1346  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1347  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1348  *	each A-MPDU
1349  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1350  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1351  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1352  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1353  *	on this subframe
1354  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1355  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1356  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1357  *	done by the hardware
1358  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1359  *	processing it in any regular way.
1360  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1361  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1362  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1363  *	monitor interfaces.
1364  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1365  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1366  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1367  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1368  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1369  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1370  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1371  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1372  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1373  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1374  *	interleaved with other frames.
1375  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1376  *	radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1377  *	the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
1378  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1379  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1380  *	the first subframe.
1381  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1382  *	be done in the hardware.
1383  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1384  *	frame
1385  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1386  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1387  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1388  *
1389  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1390  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1391  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1392  *	 - DATA5_GI
1393  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1394  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1395  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1396  *
1397  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1398  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1399  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1400  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1401  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1402  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1403  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1404  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1405  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1406  *	hardware or driver)
1407  */
1408 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1409 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1410 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1411 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1412 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1413 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1414 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1415 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1416 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1417 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1418 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1419 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1420 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1421 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1422 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1423 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1424 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1425 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1426 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1427 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1428 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1429 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA	= BIT(20),
1430 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1431 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1432 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1433 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1434 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1435 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1436 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1437 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1438 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1439 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1440 };
1441 
1442 /**
1443  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1444  *
1445  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1446  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1447  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1448  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1449  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1450  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1451  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1452  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1453  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1454  */
1455 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1456 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1457 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1458 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1459 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1460 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1461 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1462 };
1463 
1464 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1465 
1466 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1467 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1468 	RX_ENC_HT,
1469 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1470 	RX_ENC_HE,
1471 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1472 };
1473 
1474 /**
1475  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1476  *
1477  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1478  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1479  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1480  *
1481  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1482  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1483  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1484  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1485  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1486  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1487  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1488  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1489  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1490  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1491  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1492  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1493  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1494  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1495  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1496  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1497  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1498  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1499  *	values were filled.
1500  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1501  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1502  * @antenna: antenna used
1503  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1504  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1505  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1506  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1507  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1508  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1509  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1510  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1511  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1512  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1513  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1514  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1515  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1516  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1517  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1518  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1519  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1520  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1521  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1522  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1523  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1524  *	@link_valid.
1525  */
1526 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1527 	u64 mactime;
1528 	union {
1529 		u64 boottime_ns;
1530 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1531 	};
1532 	u32 device_timestamp;
1533 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1534 	u32 flag;
1535 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1536 	u8 enc_flags;
1537 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1538 	union {
1539 		struct {
1540 			u8 he_ru:3;
1541 			u8 he_gi:2;
1542 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1543 		};
1544 		struct {
1545 			u8 ru:4;
1546 			u8 gi:2;
1547 		} eht;
1548 	};
1549 	u8 rate_idx;
1550 	u8 nss;
1551 	u8 rx_flags;
1552 	u8 band;
1553 	u8 antenna;
1554 	s8 signal;
1555 	u8 chains;
1556 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1557 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1558 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1559 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1560 };
1561 
1562 static inline u32
1563 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1564 {
1565 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1566 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1567 }
1568 
1569 /**
1570  * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1571  * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1572  *	(this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1573  *	 bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1574  * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1575  *	alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1576  *	description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1577  *	Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1578  * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1579  * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1580  * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1581  *	then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1582  *	@data field.
1583  * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1584  *	the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1585  *	length
1586  * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1587  *
1588  * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1589  * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1590  * data.
1591  */
1592 struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1593 	u32 present;
1594 	u8 align;
1595 	u8 oui[3];
1596 	u8 subns;
1597 	u8 pad;
1598 	u16 len;
1599 	u8 data[];
1600 } __packed;
1601 
1602 /**
1603  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1604  *
1605  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1606  *
1607  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1608  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1609  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1610  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1611  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1612  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1613  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1614  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1615  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1616  *	for more.
1617  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1618  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1619  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1620  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1621  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1622  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1623  *	operating channel.
1624  */
1625 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1626 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1627 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1628 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1629 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1630 };
1631 
1632 
1633 /**
1634  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1635  *
1636  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1637  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1638  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1639  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1640  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1641  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1642  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1643  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1644  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1645  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1646  */
1647 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1648 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1649 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1650 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1651 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1652 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1653 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1654 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1655 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1656 };
1657 
1658 /**
1659  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1660  *
1661  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1662  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1663  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1664  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1665  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1666  */
1667 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1668 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1669 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1670 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1671 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1672 
1673 	/* keep last */
1674 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1675 };
1676 
1677 /**
1678  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1679  *
1680  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1681  *
1682  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1683  *
1684  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1685  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1686  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1687  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1688  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1689  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1690  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1691  *
1692  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1693  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1694  *
1695  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1696  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1697  *
1698  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1699  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1700  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1701  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1702  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1703  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1704  *
1705  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1706  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1707  *	configured for an HT channel.
1708  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1709  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1710  */
1711 struct ieee80211_conf {
1712 	u32 flags;
1713 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1714 
1715 	u16 listen_interval;
1716 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1717 
1718 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1719 
1720 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1721 	bool radar_enabled;
1722 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1723 };
1724 
1725 /**
1726  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1727  *
1728  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1729  * operation.
1730  *
1731  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1732  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1733  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1734  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1735  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1736  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1737  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1738  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1739  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1740  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1741  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1742   *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1743   *	channel, expressed in TU.
1744  */
1745 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1746 	u64 timestamp;
1747 	u32 device_timestamp;
1748 	bool block_tx;
1749 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1750 	u8 count;
1751 	u32 delay;
1752 };
1753 
1754 /**
1755  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1756  *
1757  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1758  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1759  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1760  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1761  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1762  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1763  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1764  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1765  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1766  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1767  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1768  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1769  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1770  */
1771 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1772 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1773 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1774 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1775 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1776 };
1777 
1778 
1779 /**
1780  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1781  *
1782  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1783  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1784  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1785  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1786  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1787  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1788  *	mac80211.
1789  */
1790 
1791 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1792 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1793 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1794 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1795 };
1796 
1797 /**
1798  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1799  * @assoc: association status
1800  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1801  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1802  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1803  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1804  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1805  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1806  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1807  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1808  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1809  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1810  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1811  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1812  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1813  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1814  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1815  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1816  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1817  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1818  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1819  *	(station mode only)
1820  */
1821 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1822 	/* association related data */
1823 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1824 	bool ibss_creator;
1825 	bool ps;
1826 	u16 aid;
1827 
1828 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1829 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1830 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1831 	size_t ssid_len;
1832 	bool s1g;
1833 	bool idle;
1834 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1835 };
1836 
1837 /**
1838  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1839  *
1840  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1841  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1842  *
1843  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1844  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1845  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1846  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1847  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1848  *	indexed by link ID
1849  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1850  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1851  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1852  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1853  * @addr: address of this interface
1854  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1855  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1856  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1857  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1858  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1859  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1860  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1861  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1862  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1863  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1864  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1865  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1866  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1867  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1868  *	restrictions.
1869  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1870  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1871  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1872  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1873  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1874  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1875  *	interface.
1876  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1877  *	for this interface.
1878  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1879  *	sizeof(void \*).
1880  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1881  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1882  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1883  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1884  */
1885 struct ieee80211_vif {
1886 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1887 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1888 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1889 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1890 	u16 valid_links, active_links;
1891 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1892 	bool p2p;
1893 
1894 	u8 cab_queue;
1895 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1896 
1897 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1898 
1899 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1900 	u32 driver_flags;
1901 	u32 offload_flags;
1902 
1903 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1904 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1905 #endif
1906 
1907 	bool probe_req_reg;
1908 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1909 
1910 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1911 
1912 	/* must be last */
1913 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1914 };
1915 
1916 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1917 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1918 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1919 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1920 		    (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1921 
1922 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1923 {
1924 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1925 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1926 #endif
1927 	return false;
1928 }
1929 
1930 /**
1931  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1932  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1933  *
1934  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1935  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1936  *
1937  * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1938  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1939  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1940  */
1941 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1942 
1943 /**
1944  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1945  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1946  *
1947  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1948  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1949  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1950  */
1951 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1952 
1953 /**
1954  * lockdep_vif_mutex_held - for lockdep checks on link poiners
1955  * @vif: the interface to check
1956  */
1957 static inline bool lockdep_vif_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1958 {
1959 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->mtx);
1960 }
1961 
1962 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1963 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1964 				  lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1965 
1966 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1967 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1968 			      lockdep_vif_mutex_held(vif))
1969 
1970 /**
1971  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1972  *
1973  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1974  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1975  *
1976  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1977  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1978  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1979  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1980  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1981  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1982  *	generation in software.
1983  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1984  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1985  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1986  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1987  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
1988  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1989  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1990  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1991  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1992  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1993  *	MIC.
1994  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1995  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1996  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1997  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1998  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1999  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2000  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2001  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2002  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2003  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2004  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2005  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2006  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2007  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2008  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2009  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2010  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2011  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2012  *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2013  *	generation only
2014  */
2015 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2016 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2017 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2018 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2019 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2020 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2021 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2022 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2023 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2024 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2025 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2026 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2027 };
2028 
2029 /**
2030  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2031  *
2032  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2033  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2034  *
2035  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2036  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2037  *	encrypted in hardware.
2038  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2039  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2040  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2041  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2042  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2043  * @keylen: key material length
2044  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2045  * 	data block:
2046  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2047  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2048  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2049  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2050  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2051  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2052  */
2053 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2054 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2055 	u32 cipher;
2056 	u8 icv_len;
2057 	u8 iv_len;
2058 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2059 	s8 keyidx;
2060 	u16 flags;
2061 	s8 link_id;
2062 	u8 keylen;
2063 	u8 key[];
2064 };
2065 
2066 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2067 
2068 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2069 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2070 
2071 /**
2072  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2073  *
2074  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2075  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2076  *	reverse order than in packet)
2077  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2078  *	reverse order than in packet)
2079  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2080  *	reverse order than in packet)
2081  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2082  *	reverse order than in packet)
2083  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2084  */
2085 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2086 	union {
2087 		struct {
2088 			u32 iv32;
2089 			u16 iv16;
2090 		} tkip;
2091 		struct {
2092 			u8 pn[6];
2093 		} ccmp;
2094 		struct {
2095 			u8 pn[6];
2096 		} aes_cmac;
2097 		struct {
2098 			u8 pn[6];
2099 		} aes_gmac;
2100 		struct {
2101 			u8 pn[6];
2102 		} gcmp;
2103 		struct {
2104 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2105 			u8 seq_len;
2106 		} hw;
2107 	};
2108 };
2109 
2110 /**
2111  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2112  *
2113  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2114  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2115  *
2116  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2117  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2118  */
2119 enum set_key_cmd {
2120 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2121 };
2122 
2123 /**
2124  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2125  *
2126  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2127  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2128  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2129  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2130  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2131  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2132  */
2133 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2134 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2135 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2136 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2137 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2138 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2139 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2140 };
2141 
2142 /**
2143  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2144  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2145  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2146  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2147  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2148  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2149  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2150  *
2151  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2152  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2153  */
2154 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2155 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2156 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2157 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2158 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2159 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2160 };
2161 
2162 /**
2163  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2164  *
2165  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2166  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2167  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2168  */
2169 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2170 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2171 	struct {
2172 		s8 idx;
2173 		u8 count;
2174 		u8 count_cts;
2175 		u8 count_rts;
2176 		u16 flags;
2177 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2178 };
2179 
2180 /**
2181  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2182  *
2183  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2184  *
2185  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2186  *	to the STA.
2187  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2188  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2189  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2190  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2191  *	per peer TPC.
2192  */
2193 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2194 	s16 power;
2195 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2196 };
2197 
2198 /**
2199  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2200  *
2201  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2202  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2203  *
2204  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2205  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2206  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2207  *
2208  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2209  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2210  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2211  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2212  *
2213  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2214  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2215  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2216  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2217  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2218  */
2219 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2220 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2221 
2222 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2223 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2224 };
2225 
2226 /**
2227  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2228  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2229  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2230  *
2231  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2232  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2233  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2234  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2235  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2236  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2237  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2238  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2239  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2240  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2241  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2242  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2243  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2244  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2245  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2246  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2247  *	the station moves to associated state.
2248  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2249  *
2250  */
2251 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2252 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2253 
2254 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2255 	u8 link_id;
2256 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2257 
2258 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2259 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2260 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2261 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2262 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2263 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2264 
2265 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2266 
2267 	u8 rx_nss;
2268 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2269 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2270 };
2271 
2272 /**
2273  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2274  *
2275  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2276  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2277  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2278  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2279  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2280  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2281  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2282  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2283  *
2284  * @addr: MAC address
2285  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2286  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2287  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2288  *	Can be modified by driver.
2289  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2290  *	otherwise always false)
2291  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2292  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2293  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2294  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2295  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2296  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2297  * @rates: rate control selection table
2298  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2299  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2300  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2301  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2302  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2303  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2304  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2305  *	unlimited.
2306  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2307  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2308  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2309  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2310  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2311  *	is used for non-data frames
2312  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2313  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2314  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2315  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2316  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2317  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2318  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2319  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2320  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2321  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2322  *	by the AP.
2323  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2324  */
2325 struct ieee80211_sta {
2326 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2327 	u16 aid;
2328 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2329 	bool wme;
2330 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2331 	u8 max_sp;
2332 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2333 	bool tdls;
2334 	bool tdls_initiator;
2335 	bool mfp;
2336 	bool mlo;
2337 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2338 
2339 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2340 
2341 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2342 
2343 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2344 
2345 	u16 valid_links;
2346 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2347 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2348 
2349 	/* must be last */
2350 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2351 };
2352 
2353 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2354 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2355 #else
2356 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2357 {
2358 	return true;
2359 }
2360 #endif
2361 
2362 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2363 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2364 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2365 
2366 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2367 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2368 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2369 
2370 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2371 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2372 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2373 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2374 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2375 
2376 /**
2377  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2378  *
2379  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2380  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2381  *
2382  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2383  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2384  */
2385 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2386 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2387 };
2388 
2389 /**
2390  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2391  *
2392  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2393  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2394  */
2395 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2396 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2397 };
2398 
2399 /**
2400  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2401  *
2402  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2403  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2404  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2405  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2406  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2407  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2408  *
2409  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2410  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2411  */
2412 struct ieee80211_txq {
2413 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2414 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2415 	u8 tid;
2416 	u8 ac;
2417 
2418 	/* must be last */
2419 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2420 };
2421 
2422 /**
2423  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2424  *
2425  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2426  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2427  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2428  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2429  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2430  *
2431  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2432  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2433  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2434  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2435  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2436  *	algorithm.
2437  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2438  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2439  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2440  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2441  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2442  *	CCK frames.
2443  *
2444  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2445  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2446  *	the FCS at the end.
2447  *
2448  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2449  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2450  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2451  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2452  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2453  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2454  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2455  *
2456  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2457  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2458  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2459  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2460  *
2461  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2462  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2463  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2464  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2465  *
2466  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2467  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2468  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2469  *
2470  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2471  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2472  *
2473  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2474  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2475  *
2476  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2477  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2478  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2479  *
2480  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2481  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2482  *
2483  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2484  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2485  *
2486  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2487  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2488  *	the stack.
2489  *
2490  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2491  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2492  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2493  *
2494  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2495  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2496  *	dtim_period).
2497  *
2498  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2499  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2500  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2501  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2502  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2503  *	only in that case.
2504  *
2505  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2506  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2507  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2508  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2509  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2510  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2511  *
2512  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2513  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2514  *	software.
2515  *
2516  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2517  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2518  *	active interfaces.
2519  *
2520  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2521  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2522  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2523  *
2524  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2525  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2526  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2527  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2528  *	supported cipher suites.
2529  *
2530  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2531  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2532  *	for frames.
2533  *
2534  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2535  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2536  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2537  *	control for more details.
2538  *
2539  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2540  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2541  *
2542  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2543  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2544  *	is supported.
2545  *
2546  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2547  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2548  *
2549  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2550  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2551  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2552  *
2553  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2554  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2555  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2556  *	CSA frame.
2557  *
2558  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2559  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2560  *
2561  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2562  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2563  *
2564  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2565  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2566  *
2567  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2568  *	within A-MPDU.
2569  *
2570  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2571  *	for sent beacons.
2572  *
2573  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2574  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2575  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2576  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2577  *
2578  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2579  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2580  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2581  *	timeout.
2582  *
2583  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2584  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2585  *
2586  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2587  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2588  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2589  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2590  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2591  *
2592  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2593  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2594  *
2595  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2596  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2597  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2598  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2599  *
2600  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2601  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2602  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2603  *
2604  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2605  *	TDLS links.
2606  *
2607  * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2608  *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2609  *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2610  *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2611  *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2612  *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2613  *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2614  *
2615  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2616  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2617  *
2618  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2619  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2620  *
2621  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2622  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2623  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2624  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2625  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2626  *
2627  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2628  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2629  *	TXQs to start with.
2630  *
2631  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2632  *	length in tx status information
2633  *
2634  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2635  *
2636  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2637  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2638  *
2639  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2640  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2641  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2642  *
2643  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2644  *	offload
2645  *
2646  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2647  *	offload
2648  *
2649  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2650  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2651  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2652  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2653  *	the stack.
2654  *
2655  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2656  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2657  *
2658  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2659  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2660  *
2661  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2662  */
2663 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2664 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2665 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2666 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2667 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2668 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2669 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2670 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2671 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2672 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2673 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2674 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2675 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2676 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2677 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2678 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2679 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2680 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2681 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2682 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2683 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2684 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2685 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2686 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2687 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2688 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2689 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2690 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2691 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2692 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2693 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2694 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2695 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2696 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2697 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2698 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2699 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2700 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2701 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2702 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2703 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2704 	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2705 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2706 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2707 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2708 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2709 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2710 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2711 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2712 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2713 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2714 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2715 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2716 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2717 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2718 
2719 	/* keep last, obviously */
2720 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2721 };
2722 
2723 /**
2724  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2725  *
2726  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2727  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2728  *
2729  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2730  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2731  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2732  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2733  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2734  *
2735  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2736  *
2737  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2738  *	along with this structure.
2739  *
2740  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2741  *
2742  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2743  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2744  *
2745  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2746  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2747  *
2748  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2749  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2750  *
2751  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2752  *	that HW supports
2753  *
2754  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2755  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2756  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2757  *
2758  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2759  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2760  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2761  *
2762  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2763  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2764  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2765  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2766  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2767  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2768  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2769  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2770  *
2771  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2772  *	can handle.
2773  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2774  *	the hw can report back.
2775  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2776  *
2777  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2778  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2779  *	aggregation.
2780  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2781  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2782  *	it shouldn't be set.
2783  *
2784  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2785  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2786  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2787  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2788  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2789  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2790  *
2791  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2792  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2793  *
2794  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2795  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2796  *
2797  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2798  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2799  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2800  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2801  *
2802  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2803  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2804  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2805  *
2806  * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2807  *
2808  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2809  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2810  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2811  *	device_timestamp.
2812  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2813  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2814  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2815  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2816  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2817  *
2818  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2819  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2820  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2821  *
2822  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2823  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2824  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2825  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2826  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2827  *	neither enabled.
2828  *
2829  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2830  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2831  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2832  *
2833  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2834  *	device.
2835  *
2836  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2837  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2838  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2839  *
2840  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2841  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2842  *
2843  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2844  *
2845  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2846  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2847  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2848  *
2849  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2850  */
2851 struct ieee80211_hw {
2852 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2853 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2854 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2855 	void *priv;
2856 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2857 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2858 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2859 	int vif_data_size;
2860 	int sta_data_size;
2861 	int chanctx_data_size;
2862 	int txq_data_size;
2863 	u16 queues;
2864 	u16 max_listen_interval;
2865 	s8 max_signal;
2866 	u8 max_rates;
2867 	u8 max_report_rates;
2868 	u8 max_rate_tries;
2869 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2870 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2871 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2872 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2873 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2874 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2875 	struct {
2876 		int units_pos;
2877 		s16 accuracy;
2878 	} radiotap_timestamp;
2879 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2880 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2881 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2882 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2883 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2884 	u8 weight_multiplier;
2885 	u32 max_mtu;
2886 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2887 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2888 };
2889 
2890 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2891 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2892 {
2893 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2894 }
2895 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2896 
2897 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2898 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2899 {
2900 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2901 }
2902 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2903 
2904 /**
2905  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2906  *
2907  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2908  * @req: cfg80211 request.
2909  */
2910 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2911 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2912 
2913 	/* Keep last */
2914 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2915 };
2916 
2917 /**
2918  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2919  *
2920  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2921  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2922  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2923  * @status: channel-switch response status
2924  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2925  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2926  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2927  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2928  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2929  */
2930 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2931 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2932 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2933 	u8 action_code;
2934 	u32 status;
2935 	u32 timestamp;
2936 	u16 switch_time;
2937 	u16 switch_timeout;
2938 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2939 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2940 };
2941 
2942 /**
2943  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2944  *
2945  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2946  *
2947  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2948  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2949  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2950  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2951  * is already used internally by mac80211.
2952  *
2953  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2954  */
2955 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2956 
2957 /**
2958  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2959  *
2960  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2961  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2962  */
2963 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2964 {
2965 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2966 }
2967 
2968 /**
2969  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2970  *
2971  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2972  * @addr: the address to set
2973  */
2974 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2975 {
2976 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2977 }
2978 
2979 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2980 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2981 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2982 {
2983 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2984 		return NULL;
2985 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2986 }
2987 
2988 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2989 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2990 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2991 {
2992 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2993 		return NULL;
2994 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2995 }
2996 
2997 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2998 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2999 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3000 {
3001 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3002 		return NULL;
3003 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3004 }
3005 
3006 /**
3007  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3008  * @hw: the hardware
3009  * @skb: the skb
3010  *
3011  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3012  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3013  */
3014 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3015 
3016 /**
3017  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3018  *
3019  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3020  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3021  *
3022  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3023  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3024  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3025  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3026  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3027  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3028  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3029  *
3030  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3031  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3032  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3033  *
3034  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3035  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3036  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3037  * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
3038  *
3039  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3040  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3041  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3042  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3043  *
3044  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3045  *
3046  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3047  * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3048  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3049  * based on the receive flags.
3050  *
3051  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3052  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3053  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3054  * keys.
3055  *
3056  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3057  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3058  * handler.
3059  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3060  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3061  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3062  * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3063  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3064  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3065  *
3066  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3067  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3068  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3069  *
3070  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3071  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3072  * requirements:
3073  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3074       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3075    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3076       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3077    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3078       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3079       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3080    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3081    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3082  */
3083 
3084 /**
3085  * DOC: Powersave support
3086  *
3087  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3088  *
3089  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3090  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3091  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3092  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3093  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3094  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3095  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3096  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3097  *
3098  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3099  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3100  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3101  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3102  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3103  *
3104  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3105  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3106  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3107  *
3108  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3109  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3110  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3111  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3112  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3113  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3114  * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3115  *
3116  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3117  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3118  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3119  * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3120  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3121  * periods.
3122  *
3123  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3124  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3125  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3126  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3127  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3128  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3129  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3130  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3131  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3132  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3133  *
3134  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3135  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3136  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3137  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3138  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3139  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3140  *
3141  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3142  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3143  */
3144 
3145 /**
3146  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3147  *
3148  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3149  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3150  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3151  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3152  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3153  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3154  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3155  *
3156  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3157  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3158  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3159  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3160  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3161  *
3162  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3163  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3164  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3165  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3166  *
3167  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3168  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3169  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3170  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3171  *
3172  *  - a list of information element IDs
3173  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3174  *
3175  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3176  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3177  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3178  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3179  * vendor information elements.
3180  *
3181  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3182  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3183  *
3184  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3185  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3186  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3187  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3188  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3189  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3190  *
3191  *
3192  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3193  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3194  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3195  * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3196  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3197  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3198  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3199  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3200  *
3201  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3202  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3203  * signal strength threshold checking.
3204  */
3205 
3206 /**
3207  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3208  *
3209  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3210  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3211  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3212  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3213  *
3214  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3215  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3216  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3217  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3218  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3219  * hardware flags.
3220  *
3221  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3222  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3223  * turned off otherwise.
3224  *
3225  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3226  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3227  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3228  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3229  */
3230 
3231 /**
3232  * DOC: Frame filtering
3233  *
3234  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3235  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3236  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3237  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3238  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3239  *
3240  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3241  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3242  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3243  *
3244  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3245  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3246  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3247  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3248  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3249  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3250  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3251  *
3252  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3253  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3254  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3255  * or dropped.
3256  *
3257  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3258  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3259  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3260  * the flag, but not clear it.
3261  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3262  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3263  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3264  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3265  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3266  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3267  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3268  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3269  */
3270 
3271 /**
3272  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3273  *
3274  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3275  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3276  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3277  *
3278  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3279  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3280  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3281  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3282  * the driver code.
3283  *
3284  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3285  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3286  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3287  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3288  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3289  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3290  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3291  *
3292  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3293  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3294  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3295  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3296  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3297  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3298  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3299  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3300  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3301  * @sta_notify callback.
3302  *
3303  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3304  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3305  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3306  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3307  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3308  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3309  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3310  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3311  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3312  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3313  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3314  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3315  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3316  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3317  *
3318  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3319  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3320  *
3321  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3322  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3323  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3324  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3325  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3326  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3327  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3328  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3329  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3330  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3331  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3332  *
3333  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3334  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3335  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3336  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3337  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3338  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3339  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3340  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3341  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3342  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3343  * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3344  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3345  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3346  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3347  *
3348  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3349  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3350  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3351  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3352  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3353  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3354  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3355  *
3356  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3357  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3358  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3359  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3360  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3361  *
3362  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3363  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3364  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3365  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3366  */
3367 
3368 /**
3369  * DOC: HW queue control
3370  *
3371  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3372  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3373  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3374  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3375  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3376  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3377  *
3378  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3379  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3380  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3381  *
3382  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3383  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3384  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3385  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3386  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3387  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3388  * the hardware queue.
3389  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3390  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3391  *
3392  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3393  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3394  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3395  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3396  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3397  *
3398  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3399  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3400  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3401  * off-channel queue:         9
3402  *
3403  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3404  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3405  *
3406  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3407  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3408  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3409  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3410  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3411  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3412  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3413  *
3414  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3415  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3416  *
3417  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3418  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3419  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3420  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3421  */
3422 
3423 /**
3424  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3425  *
3426  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3427  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3428  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3429  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3430  *
3431  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3432  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3433  *	multicast address.
3434  *
3435  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3436  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3437  *
3438  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3439  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3440  *
3441  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3442  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3443  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3444  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3445  *	honour this flag if possible.
3446  *
3447  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3448  *	station
3449  *
3450  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3451  *
3452  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3453  *
3454  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3455  *
3456  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3457  */
3458 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3459 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3460 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3461 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3462 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3463 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3464 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3465 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3466 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3467 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3468 };
3469 
3470 /**
3471  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3472  *
3473  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3474  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3475  *
3476  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3477  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3478  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3479  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3480  *
3481  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3482  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3483  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3484  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3485  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3486  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3487  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3488  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3489  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3490  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3491  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3492  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3493  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3494  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3495  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3496  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3497  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3498  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3499  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3500  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3501  */
3502 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3503 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3504 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3505 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3506 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3507 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3508 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3509 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3510 };
3511 
3512 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3513 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3514 
3515 /**
3516  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3517  *
3518  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3519  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3520  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3521  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3522  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3523  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3524  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3525  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3526  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3527  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3528  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3529  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3530  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3531  */
3532 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3533 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3534 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3535 	u16 tid;
3536 	u16 ssn;
3537 	u16 buf_size;
3538 	bool amsdu;
3539 	u16 timeout;
3540 };
3541 
3542 /**
3543  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3544  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3545  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3546  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3547  */
3548 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3549 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3550 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3551 };
3552 
3553 /**
3554  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3555  *
3556  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3557  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3558  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3559  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3560  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3561  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3562  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3563  *	the peer.
3564  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3565  *	by the peer
3566  */
3567 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3568 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3569 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3570 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3571 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3572 };
3573 
3574 /**
3575  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3576  *
3577  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3578  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3579  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3580  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3581  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3582  *
3583  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3584  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3585  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3586  */
3587 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3588 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3589 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3590 };
3591 
3592 /**
3593  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3594  *
3595  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3596  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3597  *
3598  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3599  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3600  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3601  *	of wowlan configuration)
3602  */
3603 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3604 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3605 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3606 };
3607 
3608 /**
3609  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3610  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3611  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3612  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3613  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3614  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3615  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3616  */
3617 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3618 	u16 duration;
3619 	u16 subtype;
3620 	u8 success:1;
3621 };
3622 
3623 /**
3624  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3625  *
3626  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3627  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3628  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3629  *
3630  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3631  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3632  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3633  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3634  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3635  *	Must be atomic.
3636  *
3637  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3638  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3639  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3640  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3641  *	or zero.
3642  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3643  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3644  *	is added.
3645  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3646  *
3647  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3648  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3649  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3650  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3651  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3652  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3653  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3654  *
3655  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3656  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3657  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3658  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3659  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3660  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3661  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3662  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3663  *	must return 1 from this function.
3664  *
3665  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3666  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3667  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3668  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3669  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3670  *
3671  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3672  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3673  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3674  *	in suspend().
3675  *
3676  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3677  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3678  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3679  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3680  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3681  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3682  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3683  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3684  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3685  *
3686  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3687  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3688  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3689  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3690  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3691  *
3692  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3693  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3694  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3695  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3696  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3697  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3698  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3699  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3700  *
3701  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3702  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3703  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3704  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3705  *
3706  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3707  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3708  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3709  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3710  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3711  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3712  *	can sleep.
3713  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3714  *	are not implemented.
3715  *
3716  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3717  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3718  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3719  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3720  *	The callback can sleep.
3721  *
3722  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3723  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3724  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3725  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3726  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3727  *	non-MLO connections.
3728  *	The callback can sleep.
3729  *
3730  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3731  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3732  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3733  *
3734  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3735  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3736  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3737  *
3738  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3739  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3740  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3741  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3742  *	which flags are changed.
3743  *	This callback can sleep.
3744  *
3745  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3746  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3747  *
3748  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3749  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3750  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3751  *	is enabled.
3752  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3753  *	The callback can sleep.
3754  *
3755  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3756  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3757  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3758  *	The callback must be atomic.
3759  *
3760  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3761  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3762  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3763  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3764  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3765  *
3766  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3767  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3768  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3769  *
3770  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3771  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3772  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3773  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3774  *	that power save is disabled.
3775  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3776  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3777  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3778  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3779  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3780  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3781  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3782  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3783  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3784  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3785  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3786  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3787  *	The callback can sleep.
3788  *
3789  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3790  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3791  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3792  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3793  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3794  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3795  *	The callback can sleep.
3796  *
3797  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3798  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3799  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3800  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3801  *
3802  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3803  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3804  *
3805  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3806  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3807  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3808  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3809  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3810  *
3811  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3812  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3813  *	this notification.
3814  *	The callback can sleep.
3815  *
3816  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3817  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3818  *	The callback can sleep.
3819  *
3820  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3821  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3822  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3823  *	The callback must be atomic.
3824  *
3825  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3826  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3827  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3828  *	should be set as well.
3829  *	The callback can sleep.
3830  *
3831  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3832  *	The callback can sleep.
3833  *
3834  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3835  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3836  *
3837  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3838  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3839  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3840  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3841  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3842  *	This callback can sleep.
3843  *
3844  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3845  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3846  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3847  *	callback can sleep.
3848  *
3849  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3850  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3851  *	should be within a CPTCFG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3852  *	callback can sleep.
3853  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3854  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3855  *
3856  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3857  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3858  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3859  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3860  *
3861  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3862  *	power for the station.
3863  *	This callback can sleep.
3864  *
3865  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3866  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3867  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3868  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3869  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3870  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3871  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3872  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3873  *	The callback can sleep.
3874  *
3875  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3876  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3877  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3878  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3879  *	in @sta_state.
3880  *	The callback can sleep.
3881  *
3882  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3883  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3884  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3885  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3886  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3887  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3888  *	Must be atomic.
3889  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3890  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3891  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3892  *
3893  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3894  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3895  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3896  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3897  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3898  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3899  *	The callback can sleep.
3900  *
3901  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3902  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3903  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3904  *	The callback can sleep.
3905  *
3906  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3907  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3908  *	required function.
3909  *	The callback can sleep.
3910  *
3911  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3912  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3913  *	required function.
3914  *	The callback can sleep.
3915  *
3916  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3917  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3918  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3919  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3920  *	The callback can sleep.
3921  *
3922  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3923  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3924  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3925  *	TSF synchronization.
3926  *	The callback can sleep.
3927  *
3928  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3929  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3930  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3931  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3932  *	The callback can sleep.
3933  *
3934  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3935  *
3936  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3937  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3938  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3939  *	The callback can sleep.
3940  *
3941  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3942  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3943  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3944  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3945  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3946  *
3947  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3948  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3949  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3950  *
3951  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3952  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3953  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3954  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3955  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3956  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3957  *	The callback can sleep.
3958  *
3959  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3960  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3961  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3962  *	completion of the channel switch.
3963  *
3964  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3965  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3966  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3967  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3968  *
3969  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3970  *
3971  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3972  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3973  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3974  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3975  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3976  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3977  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3978  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3979  *	must be accepted in this case.
3980  *	This callback may sleep.
3981  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3982  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3983  *
3984  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3985  *
3986  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3987  *
3988  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3989  *	queues before entering power save.
3990  *
3991  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3992  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3993  *	The callback can sleep.
3994  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3995  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3996  *	The callback must be atomic.
3997  *
3998  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3999  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4000  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4001  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4002  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4003  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4004  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4005  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4006  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4007  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4008  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4009  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4010  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4011  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4012  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4013  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4014  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4015  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4016  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4017  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4018  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4019  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4020  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4021  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4022  *	This callback must be atomic.
4023  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4024  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4025  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4026  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4027  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4028  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4029  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4030  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4031  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4032  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4033  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4034  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4035  *	This callback must be atomic.
4036  *
4037  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4038  *
4039  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4040  *
4041  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4042  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4043  *
4044  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4045  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4046  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4047  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4048  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4049  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4050  *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4051  *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4052  *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4053  *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4054  *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4055  *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4056  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4057  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4058  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4059  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4060  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4061  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4062  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4063  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4064  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4065  *
4066  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4067  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4068  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4069  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4070  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4071  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4072  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4073  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4074  *
4075  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4076  *	This callback may sleep.
4077  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4078  *	This callback may sleep.
4079  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4080  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4081  *	channel context with different settings
4082  *	This callback may sleep.
4083  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4084  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4085  *	This callback may sleep.
4086  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4087  *	unbound from vif.
4088  *	This callback may sleep.
4089  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4090  *	another, as specified in the list of
4091  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4092  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4093  *	This callback may sleep.
4094  *
4095  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4096  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4097  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4098  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4099  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4100  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4101  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4102  *
4103  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4104  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4105  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4106  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4107  *	This callback may sleep.
4108  *
4109  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4110  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4111  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4112  *
4113  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4114  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4115  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4116  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4117  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4118  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4119  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4120  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4121  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4122  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4123  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4124  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4125  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4126  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4127  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4128  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4129  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4130  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4131  *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4132  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4133  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4134  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4135  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4136  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4137  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4138  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4139  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4140  *
4141  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4142  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4143  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4144  *
4145  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4146  *	and hardware limits.
4147  *
4148  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4149  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4150  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4151  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4152  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4153  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4154  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4155  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4156  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4157  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4158  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4159  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4160  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4161  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4162  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4163  *	the function call.
4164  *
4165  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4166  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4167  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4168  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4169  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4170  *
4171  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4172  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4173  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4174  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4175  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4176  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4177  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4178  *	changed parameters.
4179  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4180  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4181  *	this call.
4182  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4183  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4184  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4185  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4186  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4187  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4188  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4189  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4190  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4191  *
4192  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4193  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4194  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4195  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4196  *	This callback may sleep.
4197  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4198  *	This callback may sleep.
4199  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4200  *	4-address mode
4201  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4202  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4203  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4204  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4205  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4206  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4207  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4208  *	twt structure.
4209  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4210  *	from the peer.
4211  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4212  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4213  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4214  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4215  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4216  *	radar channel.
4217  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4218  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4219  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4220  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4221  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4222  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4223  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4224  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4225  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4226  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4227  *	This callback can sleep.
4228  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4229  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4230  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4231  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4232  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4233  */
4234 struct ieee80211_ops {
4235 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4236 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4237 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4238 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4239 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4240 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4241 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4242 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4243 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4244 #endif
4245 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4246 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4247 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4248 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4249 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4250 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4251 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4252 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4253 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4254 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4255 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4256 				 u64 changed);
4257 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4258 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4259 				u64 changed);
4260 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4261 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4262 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4263 				  u64 changed);
4264 
4265 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4266 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4267 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4268 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4269 
4270 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4271 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4272 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4273 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4274 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4275 				 u64 multicast);
4276 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4277 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4278 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4279 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4280 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4281 		       bool set);
4282 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4283 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4284 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4285 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4286 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4287 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4288 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4289 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4290 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4291 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4292 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4293 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4294 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4295 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4296 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4297 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4298 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4299 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4300 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4301 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4302 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4303 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4304 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4305 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4306 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4307 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4308 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4309 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4310 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4311 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4312 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4313 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4314 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4315 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4316 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4317 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4318 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4319 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4320 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4321 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4322 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4323 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4324 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4325 				struct dentry *dir);
4326 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4327 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4328 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4329 				     struct dentry *dir);
4330 #endif
4331 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4332 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4333 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4334 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4335 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4336 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4337 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4338 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4339 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4340 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4341 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4342 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4343 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4344 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4345 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4346 			      u32 changed);
4347 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4348 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4349 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4350 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4351 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4352 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4353 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4354 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4355 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4356 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4357 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4358 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4359 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4360 			u64 tsf);
4361 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4362 			   s64 offset);
4363 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4364 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4365 
4366 	/**
4367 	 * @ampdu_action:
4368 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4369 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4370 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4371 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4372 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4373 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4374 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4375 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4376 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4377 	 *
4378 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4379 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4380 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4381 	 *
4382 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4383 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4384 	 *
4385 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4386 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4387 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4388 	 *
4389 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4390 	 *
4391 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4392 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4393 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4394 	 *
4395 	 * The callback can sleep.
4396 	 */
4397 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4398 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4399 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4400 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4401 		struct survey_info *survey);
4402 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4403 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4404 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4405 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4406 			    void *data, int len);
4407 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4408 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4409 			     void *data, int len);
4410 #endif
4411 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4412 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4413 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4414 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4415 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4416 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4417 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4418 
4419 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4420 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4421 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4422 				 int duration,
4423 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4424 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4425 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4426 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4427 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4428 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4429 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4430 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4431 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4432 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4433 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4434 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4435 
4436 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4437 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4438 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4439 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4440 				      bool more_data);
4441 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4442 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4443 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4444 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4445 					bool more_data);
4446 
4447 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4448 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4449 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4450 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4451 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4452 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4453 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4454 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4455 
4456 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4457 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4458 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4459 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4460 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4461 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4462 
4463 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4464 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4465 
4466 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4467 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4468 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4469 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4470 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4471 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4472 			       u32 changed);
4473 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4474 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4475 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4476 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4477 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4478 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4479 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4480 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4481 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4482 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4483 				  int n_vifs,
4484 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4485 
4486 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4487 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4488 
4489 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4490 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4491 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4492 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4493 #endif
4494 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4495 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4496 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4497 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4498 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4499 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4500 
4501 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4502 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4503 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4504 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4505 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4506 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4507 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4508 
4509 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4510 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4511 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4512 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4513 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4514 			   int *dbm);
4515 
4516 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4517 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4518 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4519 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4520 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4521 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4522 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4523 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4524 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4525 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4526 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4527 
4528 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4529 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4530 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4531 
4532 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4533 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4534 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4535 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4536 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4537 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4538 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4539 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4540 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4541 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4542 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4543 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4544 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4545 			    u8 instance_id);
4546 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4548 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4549 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4550 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4551 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4552 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4553 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4554 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4555 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4556 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4557 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4558 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4559 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4560 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4561 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4562 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4563 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4564 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4565 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4566 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4567 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4568 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4569 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4570 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4572 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4573 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4574 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4575 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4576 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4577 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4578 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4579 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4580 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4581 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4582 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4583 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4584 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4585 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4586 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4587 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4588 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4589 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4590 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4591 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4592 };
4593 
4594 /**
4595  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4596  *
4597  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4598  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4599  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4600  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4601  * @priv_data_len.
4602  *
4603  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4604  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4605  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4606  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4607  *
4608  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4609  */
4610 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4611 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4612 					   const char *requested_name);
4613 
4614 /**
4615  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4616  *
4617  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4618  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4619  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4620  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4621  * @priv_data_len.
4622  *
4623  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4624  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4625  *
4626  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4627  */
4628 static inline
4629 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4630 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4631 {
4632 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4633 }
4634 
4635 /**
4636  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4637  *
4638  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4639  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4640  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4641  *
4642  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4643  *
4644  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4645  */
4646 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4647 
4648 /**
4649  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4650  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4651  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4652  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4653  */
4654 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4655 	int throughput;
4656 	int blink_time;
4657 };
4658 
4659 /**
4660  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4661  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4662  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4663  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4664  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4665  */
4666 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4667 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4668 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4669 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4670 };
4671 
4672 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4673 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4674 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4675 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4676 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4677 const char *
4678 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4679 				   unsigned int flags,
4680 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4681 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4682 #endif
4683 /**
4684  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4685  *
4686  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4687  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4688  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4689  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4690  *
4691  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4692  *
4693  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4694  */
4695 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4696 {
4697 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4698 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4699 #else
4700 	return NULL;
4701 #endif
4702 }
4703 
4704 /**
4705  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4706  *
4707  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4708  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4709  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4710  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4711  *
4712  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4713  *
4714  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4715  */
4716 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4717 {
4718 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4719 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4720 #else
4721 	return NULL;
4722 #endif
4723 }
4724 
4725 /**
4726  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4727  *
4728  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4729  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4730  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4731  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4732  *
4733  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4734  *
4735  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4736  */
4737 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4738 {
4739 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4740 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4741 #else
4742 	return NULL;
4743 #endif
4744 }
4745 
4746 /**
4747  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4748  *
4749  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4750  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4751  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4752  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4753  *
4754  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4755  *
4756  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4757  */
4758 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4759 {
4760 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4761 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4762 #else
4763 	return NULL;
4764 #endif
4765 }
4766 
4767 /**
4768  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4769  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4770  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4771  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4772  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4773  *
4774  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4775  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4776  *
4777  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4778  */
4779 static inline const char *
4780 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4781 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4782 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4783 {
4784 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4785 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4786 						  blink_table_len);
4787 #else
4788 	return NULL;
4789 #endif
4790 }
4791 
4792 /**
4793  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4794  *
4795  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4796  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4797  *
4798  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4799  */
4800 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4801 
4802 /**
4803  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4804  *
4805  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4806  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4807  * before calling this function.
4808  *
4809  * @hw: the hardware to free
4810  */
4811 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4812 
4813 /**
4814  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4815  *
4816  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4817  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4818  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4819  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4820  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4821  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4822  *
4823  * @hw: the hardware to restart
4824  */
4825 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4826 
4827 /**
4828  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4829  *
4830  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4831  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4832  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4833  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4834  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4835  *
4836  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4837  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4838  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4839  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4840  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4841  *
4842  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4843  *
4844  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4845  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4846  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4847  * @list: the destination list
4848  */
4849 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4850 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4851 
4852 /**
4853  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4854  *
4855  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4856  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4857  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4858  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4859  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4860  *
4861  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4862  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4863  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4864  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4865  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4866  *
4867  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4868  *
4869  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4870  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4871  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4872  * @napi: the NAPI context
4873  */
4874 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4875 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4876 
4877 /**
4878  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4879  *
4880  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4881  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4882  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4883  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4884  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4885  *
4886  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4887  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4888  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4889  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4890  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4891  *
4892  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4893  *
4894  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4895  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4896  */
4897 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4898 {
4899 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4900 }
4901 
4902 /**
4903  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4904  *
4905  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4906  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4907  *
4908  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4909  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4910  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4911  *
4912  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4913  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4914  */
4915 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4916 
4917 /**
4918  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4919  *
4920  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4921  * (internally disables bottom halves).
4922  *
4923  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4924  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4925  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4926  *
4927  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4928  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4929  */
4930 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4931 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4932 {
4933 	local_bh_disable();
4934 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4935 	local_bh_enable();
4936 }
4937 
4938 /**
4939  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4940  *
4941  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4942  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4943  * entering/leaving PS mode.
4944  *
4945  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4946  *
4947  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4948  * each other.
4949  *
4950  * @sta: currently connected sta
4951  * @start: start or stop PS
4952  *
4953  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4954  */
4955 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4956 
4957 /**
4958  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4959  *                                  (in process context)
4960  *
4961  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4962  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4963  * applies.
4964  *
4965  * @sta: currently connected sta
4966  * @start: start or stop PS
4967  *
4968  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4969  */
4970 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4971 						  bool start)
4972 {
4973 	int ret;
4974 
4975 	local_bh_disable();
4976 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4977 	local_bh_enable();
4978 
4979 	return ret;
4980 }
4981 
4982 /**
4983  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4984  * @sta: currently connected station
4985  *
4986  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4987  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4988  * connected station was received.
4989  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4990  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4991  * be serialized.
4992  */
4993 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4994 
4995 /**
4996  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4997  * @sta: currently connected station
4998  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4999  *
5000  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5001  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5002  * from a connected station was received.
5003  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5004  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5005  * serialized.
5006  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5007  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5008  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5009  * checks.
5010  */
5011 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5012 
5013 /*
5014  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5015  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5016  */
5017 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5018 
5019 /**
5020  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5021  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5022  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5023  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5024  *
5025  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5026  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5027  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5028  *
5029  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5030  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5031  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5032  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5033  *
5034  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5035  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5036  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5037  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5038  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5039  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5040  *
5041  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5042  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5043  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5044  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5045  * use this API.
5046  */
5047 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5048 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5049 
5050 /**
5051  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5052  *
5053  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5054  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5055  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5056  *
5057  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5058  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5059  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5060  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5061  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5062  */
5063 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5064 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5065 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5066 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5067 			    int max_rates);
5068 
5069 /**
5070  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5071  *
5072  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5073  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5074  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5075  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5076  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5077  * slow stations to starve).
5078  *
5079  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5080  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5081  */
5082 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5083 					   u32 thr);
5084 
5085 /**
5086  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5087  *
5088  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5089  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5090  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5091  *
5092  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5093  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5094  * @info: tx status information
5095  */
5096 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5097 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5098 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5099 
5100 /**
5101  * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5102  *
5103  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5104  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5105  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5106  *
5107  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5108  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5109  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5110  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5111  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5112  *
5113  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5114  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5115  */
5116 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5117 			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5118 
5119 /**
5120  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5121  *
5122  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5123  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5124  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5125  *
5126  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5127  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5128  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5129  *
5130  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5131  * @status: tx status information
5132  */
5133 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5134 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5135 
5136 /**
5137  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5138  *
5139  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5140  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5141  * specific skbs.
5142  *
5143  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5144  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5145  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5146  *
5147  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5148  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5149  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5150  * @info: tx status information
5151  */
5152 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5153 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5154 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5155 {
5156 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5157 		.sta = sta,
5158 		.info = info,
5159 	};
5160 
5161 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5162 }
5163 
5164 /**
5165  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5166  *
5167  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5168  *
5169  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5170  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5171  * for a single hardware.
5172  *
5173  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5174  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5175  */
5176 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5177 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5178 {
5179 	local_bh_disable();
5180 	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5181 	local_bh_enable();
5182 }
5183 
5184 /**
5185  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5186  *
5187  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5188  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5189  *
5190  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5191  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5192  *
5193  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5194  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5195  */
5196 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5197 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5198 
5199 /**
5200  * ieee80211_tx_status_8023 - transmit status callback for 802.3 frame format
5201  *
5202  * Call this function for all transmitted data frames after their transmit
5203  * completion. This callback should only be called for data frames which
5204  * are using driver's (or hardware's) offload capability of encap/decap
5205  * 802.11 frames.
5206  *
5207  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5208  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other and all
5209  * calls in the same tx status family.
5210  *
5211  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5212  * @vif: the interface for which the frame was transmitted
5213  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5214  */
5215 void ieee80211_tx_status_8023(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5216 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5217 			       struct sk_buff *skb);
5218 
5219 /**
5220  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5221  *
5222  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5223  * connected STA.
5224  *
5225  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5226  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5227  */
5228 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5229 
5230 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5231 
5232 /**
5233  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5234  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5235  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5236  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5237  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5238  *	should be ignored.
5239  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5240  */
5241 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5242 	u16 tim_offset;
5243 	u16 tim_length;
5244 
5245 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5246 	u16 mbssid_off;
5247 };
5248 
5249 /**
5250  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5251  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5252  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5253  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5254  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5255  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5256  *
5257  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5258  * obtain the beacon template.
5259  *
5260  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5261  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5262  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5263  * applicable, the CSA count.
5264  *
5265  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5266  *
5267  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5268  */
5269 struct sk_buff *
5270 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5271 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5272 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5273 			      unsigned int link_id);
5274 
5275 /**
5276  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5277  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5278  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5279  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5280  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5281  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5282  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5283  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5284  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5285  *
5286  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5287  * obtain the beacon frame.
5288  *
5289  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5290  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5291  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5292  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5293  *
5294  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5295  *
5296  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5297  */
5298 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5299 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5300 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5301 					 unsigned int link_id);
5302 
5303 /**
5304  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5305  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5306  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5307  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5308  *
5309  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5310  *
5311  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5312  */
5313 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5314 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5315 						   unsigned int link_id)
5316 {
5317 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5318 }
5319 
5320 /**
5321  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5322  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5323  *
5324  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5325  * This function is called implicitly when
5326  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5327  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5328  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5329  *
5330  * Return: new countdown value
5331  */
5332 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5333 
5334 /**
5335  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5336  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5337  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5338  *
5339  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5340  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5341  *
5342  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5343  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5344  */
5345 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5346 
5347 /**
5348  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5349  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5350  *
5351  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5352  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5353  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5354  */
5355 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5356 
5357 /**
5358  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5359  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5360  *
5361  * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5362  */
5363 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5364 
5365 /**
5366  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5367  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5368  *
5369  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5370  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5371  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5372  */
5373 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5374 
5375 /**
5376  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5377  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5378  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5379  *
5380  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5381  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5382  *
5383  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5384  *
5385  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5386  */
5387 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5388 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5389 
5390 /**
5391  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5392  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5393  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5394  *
5395  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5396  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5397  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5398  *
5399  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5400  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5401  *
5402  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5403  */
5404 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5405 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5406 
5407 /**
5408  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5409  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5410  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5411  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5412  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5413  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5414  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5415  *	if at all possible
5416  *
5417  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5418  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5419  * BSSID and address is used.
5420  *
5421  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5422  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5423  *
5424  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5425  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5426  *
5427  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5428  */
5429 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5430 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5431 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5432 
5433 /**
5434  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5435  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5436  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5437  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5438  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5439  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5440  *
5441  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5442  * hardware.
5443  *
5444  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5445  */
5446 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5447 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5448 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5449 				       size_t tailroom);
5450 
5451 /**
5452  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5453  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5454  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5455  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5456  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5457  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5458  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5459  *
5460  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5461  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5462  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5463  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5464  */
5465 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5466 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5467 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5468 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5469 
5470 /**
5471  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5472  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5473  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5474  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5475  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5476  *
5477  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5478  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5479  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5480  *
5481  * Return: The duration.
5482  */
5483 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5484 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5485 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5486 
5487 /**
5488  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5489  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5490  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5491  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5492  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5493  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5494  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5495  *
5496  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5497  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5498  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5499  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5500  */
5501 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5502 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5503 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5504 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5505 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5506 
5507 /**
5508  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5509  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5510  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5511  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5512  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5513  *
5514  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5515  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5516  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5517  *
5518  * Return: The duration.
5519  */
5520 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5521 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5522 				    size_t frame_len,
5523 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5524 
5525 /**
5526  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5527  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5528  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5529  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5530  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5531  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5532  *
5533  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5534  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5535  *
5536  * Return: The duration.
5537  */
5538 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5539 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5540 					enum nl80211_band band,
5541 					size_t frame_len,
5542 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5543 
5544 /**
5545  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5546  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5547  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5548  *
5549  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5550  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5551  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5552  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5553  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5554  *
5555  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5556  * frames are available.
5557  *
5558  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5559  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5560  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5561  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5562  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5563  * use common code for all beacons.
5564  */
5565 struct sk_buff *
5566 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5567 
5568 /**
5569  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5570  *
5571  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5572  *
5573  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5574  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5575  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5576  */
5577 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5578 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5579 
5580 /**
5581  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5582  *
5583  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5584  * from the given packet.
5585  *
5586  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5587  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5588  *	with this P1K
5589  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5590  */
5591 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5592 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5593 {
5594 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5595 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5596 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5597 
5598 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5599 }
5600 
5601 /**
5602  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5603  *
5604  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5605  * and transmitter address.
5606  *
5607  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5608  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5609  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5610  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5611  */
5612 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5613 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5614 
5615 /**
5616  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5617  *
5618  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5619  * in the packet.
5620  *
5621  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5622  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5623  *	encrypted with this key
5624  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5625  */
5626 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5627 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5628 
5629 /**
5630  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5631  *
5632  * @pos: start of crypto header
5633  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5634  * @pn: PN to add
5635  *
5636  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5637  * the packet payload)
5638  *
5639  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5640  * point to the crypto header)
5641  */
5642 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5643 
5644 /**
5645  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5646  *
5647  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5648  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5649  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5650  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5651  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5652  *
5653  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5654  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5655  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5656  *
5657  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5658  * can be done concurrently.
5659  */
5660 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5661 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5662 
5663 /**
5664  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5665  *
5666  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5667  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5668  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5669  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5670  * @seq: new sequence data
5671  *
5672  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5673  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5674  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5675  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5676  *
5677  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5678  * can be done concurrently.
5679  */
5680 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5681 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5682 
5683 /**
5684  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5685  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5686  *
5687  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5688  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5689  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5690  *
5691  * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5692  * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5693  */
5694 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5695 
5696 /**
5697  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5698  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5699  * @keyconf: new key data
5700  *
5701  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5702  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5703  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5704  *
5705  * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5706  * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5707  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5708  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5709  *
5710  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5711  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5712  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5713  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5714  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5715  * of the reconfiguration.
5716  *
5717  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5718  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5719  *
5720  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5721  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5722  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5723  * the key that's being replaced.
5724  */
5725 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5726 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5727 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5728 
5729 /**
5730  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5731  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5732  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5733  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5734  * @gfp: allocation flags
5735  */
5736 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5737 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5738 
5739 /**
5740  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5741  *
5742  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5743  * at the same time.
5744  *
5745  * @keyconf: the key in question
5746  */
5747 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5748 
5749 /**
5750  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5751  *
5752  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5753  * at the same time.
5754  *
5755  * @keyconf: the key in question
5756  */
5757 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5758 
5759 /**
5760  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5761  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5762  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5763  *
5764  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5765  */
5766 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5767 
5768 /**
5769  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5770  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5771  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5772  *
5773  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5774  */
5775 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5776 
5777 /**
5778  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5779  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5780  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5781  *
5782  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5783  *
5784  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5785  */
5786 
5787 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5788 
5789 /**
5790  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5791  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5792  *
5793  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5794  */
5795 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5796 
5797 /**
5798  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5799  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5800  *
5801  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5802  */
5803 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5804 
5805 /**
5806  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5807  *
5808  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5809  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5810  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5811  * any context, including hardirq context.
5812  *
5813  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5814  * @info: information about the completed scan
5815  */
5816 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5817 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5818 
5819 /**
5820  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5821  *
5822  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5823  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5824  *
5825  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5826  */
5827 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5828 
5829 /**
5830  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5831  *
5832  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5833  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5834  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5835  * while associating, for instance.
5836  *
5837  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5838  */
5839 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5840 
5841 /**
5842  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5843  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5844  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5845  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5846  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5847  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5848  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5849  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5850  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5851  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5852  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5853  *	for instance.
5854  */
5855 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5856 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5857 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5858 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5859 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5860 };
5861 
5862 /**
5863  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5864  *
5865  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5866  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5867  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5868  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5869  *
5870  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5871  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5872  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5873  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5874  */
5875 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5876 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5877 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5878 				  void *data);
5879 
5880 /**
5881  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5882  *
5883  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5884  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5885  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5886  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5887  * be used.
5888  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5889  *
5890  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5891  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5892  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5893  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5894  */
5895 static inline void
5896 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5897 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5898 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5899 				    void *data)
5900 {
5901 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5902 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5903 				     iterator, data);
5904 }
5905 
5906 /**
5907  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5908  *
5909  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5910  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5911  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5912  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5913  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5914  *
5915  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5916  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5917  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5918  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5919  */
5920 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5921 						u32 iter_flags,
5922 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
5923 						    u8 *mac,
5924 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5925 						void *data);
5926 
5927 /**
5928  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
5929  *
5930  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5931  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5932  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
5933  *
5934  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5935  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5936  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5937  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5938  */
5939 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5940 					     u32 iter_flags,
5941 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
5942 						u8 *mac,
5943 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5944 					     void *data);
5945 
5946 /**
5947  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5948  *
5949  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5950  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5951  * function for them.
5952  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5953  *
5954  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5955  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5956  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5957  */
5958 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5959 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
5960 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5961 				       void *data);
5962 /**
5963  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5964  *
5965  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5966  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5967  *
5968  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5969  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5970  */
5971 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5972 
5973 /**
5974  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5975  *
5976  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5977  * workqueue.
5978  *
5979  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5980  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5981  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5982  */
5983 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5984 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
5985 				  unsigned long delay);
5986 
5987 /**
5988  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5989  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5990  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5991  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5992  *
5993  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5994  *
5995  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5996  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5997  * will be managed by the mac80211.
5998  */
5999 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6000 				  u16 timeout);
6001 
6002 /**
6003  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6004  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6005  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6006  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6007  *
6008  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6009  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6010  * from any context.
6011  */
6012 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6013 				      u16 tid);
6014 
6015 /**
6016  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6017  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6018  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6019  *
6020  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6021  *
6022  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6023  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6024  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6025  */
6026 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6027 
6028 /**
6029  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6030  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6031  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6032  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6033  *
6034  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6035  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6036  * can be called from any context.
6037  */
6038 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6039 				     u16 tid);
6040 
6041 /**
6042  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6043  *
6044  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6045  * @addr: station's address
6046  *
6047  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6048  *
6049  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6050  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6051  */
6052 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6053 					 const u8 *addr);
6054 
6055 /**
6056  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6057  *
6058  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6059  * @addr: remote station's address
6060  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6061  *
6062  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6063  *
6064  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6065  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6066  *
6067  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6068  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6069  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6070  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6071  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6072  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6073  *      is not reliable.
6074  *
6075  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6076  */
6077 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6078 					       const u8 *addr,
6079 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6080 
6081 /**
6082  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6083  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6084  * @addr: remote station's link address
6085  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6086  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6087  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6088  *
6089  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6090  */
6091 struct ieee80211_sta *
6092 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6093 				 const u8 *addr,
6094 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6095 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6096 
6097 /**
6098  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6099  * @hw: the hardware
6100  * @pubsta: the station
6101  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6102  *
6103  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6104  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6105  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6106  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6107  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6108  *
6109  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6110  * manner.
6111  *
6112  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6113  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6114  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6115  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6116  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6117  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6118  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6119  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6120  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6121  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6122  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6123  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6124  * woke up while blocked or not.
6125  */
6126 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6127 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6128 
6129 /**
6130  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6131  * @pubsta: the station
6132  *
6133  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6134  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6135  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6136  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6137  *
6138  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6139  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6140  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6141  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6142  *
6143  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6144  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6145  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6146  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6147  */
6148 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6149 
6150 /**
6151  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6152  * @pubsta: the station
6153  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6154  *
6155  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6156  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6157  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6158  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6159  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6160  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6161  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6162  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6163  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6164  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6165  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6166  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6167  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6168  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6169  */
6170 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6171 
6172 /**
6173  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6174  * @pubsta: the station
6175  *
6176  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6177  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6178  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6179  *
6180  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6181  * there is no need to call this function.
6182  */
6183 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6184 
6185 /**
6186  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6187  *
6188  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6189  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6190  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6191  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6192  *
6193  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6194  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6195  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6196  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6197  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6198  * attempts.
6199  *
6200  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6201  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6202  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6203  * them to 0.
6204  *
6205  * @pubsta: the station
6206  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6207  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6208  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6209  */
6210 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6211 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6212 
6213 /**
6214  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6215  *
6216  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6217  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6218  *
6219  * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6220  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6221  */
6222 bool
6223 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6224 
6225 /**
6226  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6227  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6228  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6229  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6230  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6231  *
6232  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6233  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6234  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6235  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6236  * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6237  * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6238  *
6239  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6240  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6241  * set_key callback.
6242  */
6243 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6244 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6245 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6246 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6247 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6248 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6249 				      void *data),
6250 			 void *iter_data);
6251 
6252 /**
6253  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6254  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6255  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6256  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6257  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6258  *
6259  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6260  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6261  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6262  * in removal process will be skipped.
6263  *
6264  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6265  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6266  */
6267 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6268 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6269 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6270 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6271 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6272 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6273 					  void *data),
6274 			     void *iter_data);
6275 
6276 /**
6277  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6278  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6279  * @iter: iterator function
6280  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6281  *
6282  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6283  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6284  * places while calling into the driver.
6285  *
6286  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6287  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6288  * removed.
6289  *
6290  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6291  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6292  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6293  * or not.
6294  */
6295 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6296 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6297 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6298 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6299 		     void *data),
6300 	void *iter_data);
6301 
6302 /**
6303  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6304  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6305  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6306  *
6307  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6308  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6309  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6310  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6311  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6312  * %NULL.
6313  *
6314  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6315  */
6316 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6317 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6318 
6319 /**
6320  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6321  *
6322  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6323  *
6324  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6325  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6326  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6327  */
6328 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6329 
6330 /**
6331  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6332  *
6333  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6334  *
6335  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6336  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6337  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6338  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6339  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6340  *
6341  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6342  * without connection recovery attempts.
6343  */
6344 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6345 
6346 /**
6347  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6348  *
6349  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6350  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6351  *
6352  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6353  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6354  */
6355 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6356 
6357 /**
6358  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6359  *
6360  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6361  *
6362  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6363  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6364  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6365  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6366  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6367  *
6368  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6369  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6370  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6371  * disconnect normally later.
6372  *
6373  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6374  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6375  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6376  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6377  */
6378 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6379 
6380 /**
6381  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6382  * hardware restart
6383  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6384  *
6385  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6386  * hardware restart.
6387  */
6388 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6389 
6390 /**
6391  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6392  *	rssi threshold triggered
6393  *
6394  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6395  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6396  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6397  * @gfp: context flags
6398  *
6399  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6400  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6401  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6402  */
6403 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6404 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6405 			       s32 rssi_level,
6406 			       gfp_t gfp);
6407 
6408 /**
6409  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6410  *
6411  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6412  * @gfp: context flags
6413  */
6414 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6415 
6416 /**
6417  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6418  *
6419  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6420  */
6421 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6422 
6423 /**
6424  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6425  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6426  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6427  *
6428  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6429  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6430  */
6431 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
6432 
6433 /**
6434  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6435  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6436  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6437  *
6438  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6439  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6440  * a deauth frame in this case.
6441  */
6442 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6443 					 bool block_tx);
6444 
6445 /**
6446  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6447  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6448  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6449  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6450  *
6451  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6452  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6453  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6454  */
6455 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6456 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6457 
6458 /**
6459  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6460  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6461  */
6462 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6463 
6464 /**
6465  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6466  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6467  */
6468 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6469 
6470 /**
6471  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6472  *
6473  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6474  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6475  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6476  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6477  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6478  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6479  *
6480  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6481  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6482  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6483  */
6484 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6485 				  const u8 *addr);
6486 
6487 /**
6488  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6489  * @pubsta: station struct
6490  * @tid: the session's TID
6491  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6492  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6493  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6494  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6495  *
6496  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6497  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6498  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6499  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6500  */
6501 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6502 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6503 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6504 
6505 /**
6506  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6507  *
6508  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6509  * buffer.
6510  *
6511  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6512  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6513  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6514  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6515  */
6516 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6517 
6518 /**
6519  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6520  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6521  * @addr: station mac address
6522  * @tid: the rx tid
6523  */
6524 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6525 				 unsigned int tid);
6526 
6527 /**
6528  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6529  *
6530  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6531  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6532  * reordering.
6533  *
6534  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6535  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6536  *
6537  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6538  * @addr: station mac address
6539  * @tid: the rx tid
6540  */
6541 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6542 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6543 {
6544 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6545 		return;
6546 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6547 }
6548 
6549 /**
6550  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6551  *
6552  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6553  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6554  * reordering.
6555  *
6556  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6557  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6558  *
6559  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6560  * @addr: station mac address
6561  * @tid: the rx tid
6562  */
6563 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6564 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6565 {
6566 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6567 		return;
6568 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6569 }
6570 
6571 /**
6572  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6573  *
6574  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6575  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6576  *
6577  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6578  *
6579  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6580  * @addr: station mac address
6581  * @tid: the rx tid
6582  */
6583 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6584 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6585 
6586 /* Rate control API */
6587 
6588 /**
6589  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6590  *
6591  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6592  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6593  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6594  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6595  *	to be filled in
6596  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6597  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6598  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6599  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6600  *	RTS threshold
6601  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6602  *	if the selected rate supports it
6603  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6604  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6605  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6606  */
6607 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6608 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6609 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6610 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6611 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6612 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6613 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6614 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6615 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6616 	bool bss;
6617 };
6618 
6619 /**
6620  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6621  */
6622 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6623 	/**
6624 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6625 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6626 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6627 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6628 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6629 	 */
6630 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6631 	/**
6632 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6633 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6634 	 */
6635 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6636 };
6637 
6638 struct rate_control_ops {
6639 	unsigned long capa;
6640 	const char *name;
6641 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6642 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6643 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6644 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6645 
6646 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6647 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6648 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6649 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6650 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6651 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6652 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6653 			    u32 changed);
6654 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6655 			 void *priv_sta);
6656 
6657 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6658 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6659 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6660 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6661 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6662 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6663 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6664 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6665 
6666 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6667 				struct dentry *dir);
6668 
6669 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6670 };
6671 
6672 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6673 				 enum nl80211_band band,
6674 				 int index)
6675 {
6676 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6677 }
6678 
6679 static inline s8
6680 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6681 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6682 {
6683 	int i;
6684 
6685 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6686 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6687 			return i;
6688 
6689 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6690 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6691 
6692 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6693 	return 0;
6694 }
6695 
6696 static inline
6697 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6698 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6699 {
6700 	unsigned int i;
6701 
6702 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6703 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6704 			return true;
6705 	return false;
6706 }
6707 
6708 /**
6709  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6710  *
6711  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6712  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6713  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6714  * the most recent rate control module decision.
6715  *
6716  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6717  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6718  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6719  */
6720 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6721 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6722 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6723 
6724 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6725 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6726 
6727 static inline bool
6728 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6729 {
6730 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6731 }
6732 
6733 static inline bool
6734 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6735 {
6736 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6737 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6738 }
6739 
6740 static inline bool
6741 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6742 {
6743 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6744 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6745 }
6746 
6747 static inline bool
6748 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6749 {
6750 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6751 }
6752 
6753 static inline bool
6754 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6755 {
6756 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6757 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6758 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6759 }
6760 
6761 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6762 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6763 {
6764 	if (p2p) {
6765 		switch (type) {
6766 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6767 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6768 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6769 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6770 		default:
6771 			break;
6772 		}
6773 	}
6774 	return type;
6775 }
6776 
6777 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6778 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6779 {
6780 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6781 }
6782 
6783 /**
6784  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6785  *
6786  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6787  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6788  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6789  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6790  *
6791  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6792  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6793  * matching GroupId management frame.
6794  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6795  */
6796 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6797 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6798 
6799 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6800 				   int rssi_min_thold,
6801 				   int rssi_max_thold);
6802 
6803 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6804 
6805 /**
6806  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6807  *
6808  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6809  *
6810  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6811  *
6812  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6813  * applicable.
6814  */
6815 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6816 
6817 /**
6818  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6819  * @vif: virtual interface
6820  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6821  * @gfp: allocation flags
6822  *
6823  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6824  */
6825 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6826 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6827 				    gfp_t gfp);
6828 
6829 /**
6830  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6831  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6832  * @vif: virtual interface
6833  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6834  * @band: the band to transmit on
6835  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6836  *
6837  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6838  */
6839 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6840 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6841 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6842 
6843 /**
6844  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
6845  *				 of injected frames.
6846  *
6847  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
6848  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
6849  * of the skb before calling this function.
6850  *
6851  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
6852  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
6853  */
6854 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
6855 				 struct net_device *dev);
6856 
6857 /**
6858  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6859  *
6860  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6861  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6862  *
6863  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6864  *
6865  * private:
6866  *
6867  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6868  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6869  */
6870 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6871 	u32 next_tsf;
6872 	bool has_next_tsf;
6873 
6874 	u8 absent;
6875 
6876 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6877 	struct {
6878 		u32 start;
6879 		u32 duration;
6880 		u32 interval;
6881 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6882 };
6883 
6884 /**
6885  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6886  *
6887  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6888  * @data: NoA tracking data
6889  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6890  *
6891  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6892  */
6893 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6894 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6895 
6896 /**
6897  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6898  *
6899  * @data: NoA tracking data
6900  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6901  */
6902 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6903 
6904 /**
6905  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6906  * @vif: virtual interface
6907  * @peer: the peer's destination address
6908  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6909  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6910  * @gfp: allocation flags
6911  *
6912  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6913  */
6914 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6915 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6916 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6917 
6918 /**
6919  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6920  *
6921  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6922  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6923  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6924  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6925  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6926  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6927  *
6928  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6929  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6930  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6931  *
6932  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6933  * @tid: the TID to reserve
6934  *
6935  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6936  */
6937 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6938 
6939 /**
6940  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6941  *
6942  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6943  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6944  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6945  *
6946  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6947  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6948  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6949  *
6950  * @sta: the station
6951  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6952  */
6953 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6954 
6955 /**
6956  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6957  *
6958  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6959  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6960  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6961  *
6962  * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6963  *
6964  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6965  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6966  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
6967  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6968  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6969  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6970  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6971  *
6972  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6973  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6974  */
6975 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6976 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6977 
6978 /**
6979  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6980  * (in process context)
6981  *
6982  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6983  * (internally disables bottom halves).
6984  *
6985  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6986  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6987  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
6988  */
6989 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6990 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6991 {
6992 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6993 
6994 	local_bh_disable();
6995 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6996 	local_bh_enable();
6997 
6998 	return skb;
6999 }
7000 
7001 /**
7002  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7003  *
7004  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7005  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7006  *
7007  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7008  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7009  */
7010 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7011 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7012 
7013 /**
7014  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7015  *
7016  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7017  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7018  *
7019  * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7020  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7021  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7022  */
7023 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7024 
7025 /**
7026  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7027  *
7028  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7029  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7030  *
7031  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7032  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7033  */
7034 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7035 
7036 /* (deprecated) */
7037 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7038 {
7039 }
7040 
7041 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7042 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7043 
7044 /**
7045  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7046  *
7047  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7048  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7049  *
7050  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7051  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7052  *
7053  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7054  * this TXQ internally.
7055  */
7056 static inline void
7057 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7058 {
7059 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7060 }
7061 
7062 /**
7063  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7064  *
7065  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7066  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7067  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7068  *
7069  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7070  * internally.
7071  */
7072 static inline void
7073 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7074 		     bool force)
7075 {
7076 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7077 }
7078 
7079 /**
7080  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7081  *
7082  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7083  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7084  * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7085  * next_txq().
7086  *
7087  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7088  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7089  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7090  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7091  * again.
7092  *
7093  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7094  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7095  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7096  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7097  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7098  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7099  *
7100  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7101  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7102  */
7103 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7104 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7105 
7106 /**
7107  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7108  *
7109  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7110  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7111  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7112  *
7113  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7114  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7115  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7116  */
7117 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7118 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7119 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7120 
7121 /**
7122  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7123  *
7124  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7125  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7126  *
7127  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7128  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7129  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7130  * @gfp: allocation flags
7131  */
7132 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7133 				   u8 inst_id,
7134 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7135 				   gfp_t gfp);
7136 
7137 /**
7138  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7139  *
7140  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7141  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7142  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7143  *
7144  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7145  * @match: match event information
7146  * @gfp: allocation flags
7147  */
7148 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7149 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7150 			      gfp_t gfp);
7151 
7152 /**
7153  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7154  *
7155  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7156  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7157  *
7158  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7159  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7160  *          information.
7161  * @len: frame length in bytes
7162  */
7163 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7164 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7165 			      int len);
7166 
7167 /**
7168  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7169  *
7170  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7171  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7172  *
7173  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7174  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7175  * @len: frame length in bytes
7176  */
7177 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7178 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7179 			      int len);
7180 /**
7181  * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7182  *
7183  * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7184  * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7185  * hardware or firmware.
7186  *
7187  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7188  * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7189  */
7190 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7191 
7192 /**
7193  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7194  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7195  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7196  *
7197  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7198  *
7199  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7200  */
7201 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7202 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7203 
7204 /**
7205  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7206  *	probe response template.
7207  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7208  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7209  *
7210  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7211  *
7212  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7213  */
7214 struct sk_buff *
7215 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7216 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7217 
7218 /**
7219  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7220  * collision.
7221  *
7222  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7223  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7224  *	aware of.
7225  * @gfp: allocation flags
7226  */
7227 void
7228 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7229 				      u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7230 
7231 /**
7232  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7233  *
7234  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7235  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7236  *
7237  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7238  */
7239 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7240 {
7241 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7242 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7243 
7244 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7245 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7246 }
7247 
7248 /**
7249  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7250  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7251  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7252  *
7253  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7254  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7255  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7256  *
7257  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7258  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7259  * a sequence of calls like
7260  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7261  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7262  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7263  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7264  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7265  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7266  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7267  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7268  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7269  *
7270  * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7271  *	 be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7272  *	 lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7273  */
7274 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7275 
7276 /**
7277  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7278  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7279  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7280  *
7281  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7282  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7283  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7284  * completed after it returns.
7285  */
7286 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7287 				      u16 active_links);
7288 
7289 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7290